1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2025 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26
27 /**
28 * DOC: Introduction
29 *
30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33 * drivers.
34 */
35
36 /**
37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38 *
39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44 * tasklet function.
45 *
46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48 */
49
50 /**
51 * DOC: Warning
52 *
53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55 */
56
57 /**
58 * DOC: Frame format
59 *
60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63 * hardware.
64 *
65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66 *
67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69 *
70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72 */
73
74 /**
75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76 *
77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81 *
82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83 * suspend.
84 *
85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86 *
87 */
88
89 /**
90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91 *
92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94 * different stations/interfaces.
95 *
96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98 * handler.
99 *
100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103 *
104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106 *
107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109 * driver op.
110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113 *
114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
119 *
120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124 * .release_buffered_frames().
125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128 */
129
130 /**
131 * DOC: HW timestamping
132 *
133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135 *
136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140 *
141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145 */
146 struct device;
147
148 /**
149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150 *
151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153 */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
160
161 /**
162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167 */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
173 };
174
175 /**
176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177 *
178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180 *
181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190 */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 u16 txop;
193 u16 cw_min;
194 u16 cw_max;
195 u8 aifs;
196 bool acm;
197 bool uapsd;
198 bool mu_edca;
199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208
209 /**
210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218 * bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220 * was changed.
221 */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
224 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
225 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
226 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
227 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF = BIT(4),
228 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP = BIT(5),
229 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING = BIT(6),
230 };
231
232 /**
233 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236 * (otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237 */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242
243 /**
244 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245 *
246 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248 *
249 * @def: the channel definition
250 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252 * for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262 */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267
268 int radio_idx;
269 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270
271 bool radar_enabled;
272
273 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275
276 /**
277 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
281 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288 * for changes/removal.)
289 */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294
295 /**
296 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297 *
298 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
300 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301 * done.
302 *
303 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307 */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314
315 /**
316 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317 *
318 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320 *
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322 * also implies a change in the AID.
323 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
333 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346 * changed
347 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351 * context had been assigned.
352 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355 * keep alive) changed.
356 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364 * status changed.
365 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368 */
369 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
370 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
371 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
372 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
373 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
374 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
375 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
376 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
377 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
378 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
379 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
380 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
381 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
382 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
383 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
384 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
385 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
386 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
387 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
388 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
389 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
390 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
391 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
392 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
393 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
394 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
395 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
396 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
397 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
398 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
399 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
400 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
401 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
402 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS = BIT_ULL(33),
403 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM = BIT_ULL(34),
404 BSS_CHANGED_TPE = BIT_ULL(35),
405
406 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
407 };
408
409 /*
410 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
411 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
412 * filtering will be disabled.
413 */
414 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
415
416 /**
417 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
418 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
419 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
420 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
421 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
422 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
423 * once each time the timeout triggers.
424 */
425 enum ieee80211_event_type {
426 RSSI_EVENT,
427 MLME_EVENT,
428 BAR_RX_EVENT,
429 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
430 };
431
432 /**
433 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
434 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
435 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
436 */
437 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
438 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
439 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
440 };
441
442 /**
443 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
444 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
445 */
446 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
447 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
448 };
449
450 /**
451 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
452 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
453 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
454 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
455 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
456 */
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
458 AUTH_EVENT,
459 ASSOC_EVENT,
460 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
461 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
462 };
463
464 /**
465 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
466 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
467 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
468 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
469 */
470 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
471 MLME_SUCCESS,
472 MLME_DENIED,
473 MLME_TIMEOUT,
474 };
475
476 /**
477 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
478 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
479 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
480 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
481 */
482 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
483 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
484 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
485 u16 reason;
486 };
487
488 /**
489 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
490 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
491 * @tid: the tid
492 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
493 */
494 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
495 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
496 u16 tid;
497 u16 ssn;
498 };
499
500 /**
501 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
502 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
503 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
504 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
505 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
506 * @u:union holding the fields above
507 */
508 struct ieee80211_event {
509 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
510 union {
511 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
512 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
513 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
514 } u;
515 };
516
517 /**
518 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
519 *
520 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
521 *
522 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
523 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
524 */
525 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
526 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
527 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
528 };
529
530 /**
531 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
532 *
533 * @lci: LCI subelement content
534 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
535 * @lci_len: LCI data length
536 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
537 */
538 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
539 const u8 *lci;
540 const u8 *civicloc;
541 size_t lci_len;
542 size_t civicloc_len;
543 };
544
545 /**
546 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
547 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
548 *
549 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
550 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551 */
552 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
553 u32 min_interval;
554 u32 max_interval;
555 };
556
557 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ 5
558 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
559 bool valid;
560 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
561 u8 count;
562 };
563
564 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ 16
565 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
566 bool valid;
567 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
568 u8 count, n;
569 };
570
571 /**
572 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
573 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
574 * (indexed by TX power category)
575 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
576 * 160, 320 MHz each
577 * (indexed by TX power category)
578 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
579 * subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
580 * (indexed by TX power category)
581 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
582 * each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
583 * (indexed by TX power category)
584 */
585 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
586 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
587 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
588 };
589
590 /**
591 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
592 *
593 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
594 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
595 *
596 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
597 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
598 * when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
599 * necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
600 * responses.
601 * @addr: (link) address used locally
602 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
603 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
604 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
605 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
606 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
607 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
608 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
609 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
610 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
613 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
614 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
615 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
616 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
617 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
618 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
619 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
620 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
621 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
622 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
623 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
624 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
625 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
626 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
627 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
628 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
629 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
630 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
631 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
632 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
633 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
634 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
635 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
636 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
637 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
638 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
639 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
640 * the current band.
641 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
642 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
643 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
644 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
645 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
646 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
647 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
648 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
649 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
650 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
651 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
652 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
653 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
654 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
655 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
656 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
657 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
658 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
659 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
660 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
661 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
662 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
663 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
664 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
665 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
666 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
667 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
668 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
669 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
670 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
671 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
672 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
673 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
674 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
675 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
676 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
677 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
678 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
679 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
680 * station.
681 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
682 * responder functionality.
683 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
684 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
685 * @tx_bss_conf: Pointer to the BSS configuration of transmitting interface
686 * if MBSSID is enabled. This pointer is RCU-protected due to CSA finish
687 * and BSS color change flows accessing it.
688 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
689 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
690 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
691 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
692 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
693 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
694 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
695 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
696 * connected to (STA)
697 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
698 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
699 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
700 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
701 * interval.
702 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
703 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
704 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
705 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
706 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
707 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
708 * @epcs_support: does this BSS support EPCS
709 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
710 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
711 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
712 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
713 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
714 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
715 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
716 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
717 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
718 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
719 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
720 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
721 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
722 * beamformer
723 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
724 * beamformee
725 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
726 * beamformer
727 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
728 * beamformee
729 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
730 * beamformer
731 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
732 * beamformee
733 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
734 * beamformer
735 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
736 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
737 * bandwidth
738 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
739 * beamformer
740 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
741 * beamformee
742 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
743 * beamformer
744 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
745 * reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
746 * bandwidth
747 * @eht_disable_mcs15: disable EHT-MCS 15 reception capability.
748 * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
749 * information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
750 * beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
751 * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
752 * that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
753 * its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
754 * link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
755 * bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
756 * link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
757 * In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
758 * be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
759 * the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
760 * (as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
761 * @s1g_long_beacon_period: number of beacon intervals between each long
762 * beacon transmission.
763 */
764 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
765 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
766 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
767
768 const u8 *bssid;
769 unsigned int link_id;
770 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
771 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
772 bool uora_exists;
773 u8 uora_ocw_range;
774 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
775 bool he_support;
776 bool twt_requester;
777 bool twt_responder;
778 bool twt_protected;
779 bool twt_broadcast;
780 /* erp related data */
781 bool use_cts_prot;
782 bool use_short_preamble;
783 bool use_short_slot;
784 bool enable_beacon;
785 u8 dtim_period;
786 u16 beacon_int;
787 u16 assoc_capability;
788 u64 sync_tsf;
789 u32 sync_device_ts;
790 u8 sync_dtim_count;
791 u32 basic_rates;
792 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
793 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
794 u16 ht_operation_mode;
795 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
796 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
797 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
798 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
799 struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
800 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
801 bool qos;
802 bool hidden_ssid;
803 int txpower;
804 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
805 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
806 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
807 u16 max_idle_period;
808 bool protected_keep_alive;
809 bool ftm_responder;
810 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
811 /* Multiple BSSID data */
812 bool nontransmitted;
813 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *tx_bss_conf;
814 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
815 u8 bssid_index;
816 u8 bssid_indicator;
817 bool ema_ap;
818 u8 profile_periodicity;
819 struct {
820 u32 params;
821 u16 nss_set;
822 } he_oper;
823 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
824 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
825 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
826 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
827 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
828 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
829
830 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
831
832 u8 pwr_reduction;
833 bool eht_support;
834 bool epcs_support;
835 bool csa_active;
836
837 bool mu_mimo_owner;
838 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
839
840 bool color_change_active;
841 u8 color_change_color;
842
843 bool ht_ldpc;
844 bool vht_ldpc;
845 bool he_ldpc;
846 bool vht_su_beamformer;
847 bool vht_su_beamformee;
848 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
849 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
850 bool he_su_beamformer;
851 bool he_su_beamformee;
852 bool he_mu_beamformer;
853 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
854 bool eht_su_beamformer;
855 bool eht_su_beamformee;
856 bool eht_mu_beamformer;
857 bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
858 bool eht_disable_mcs15;
859
860 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
861 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
862
863 u8 s1g_long_beacon_period;
864 };
865
866 /**
867 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
868 *
869 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
870 *
871 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
872 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
873 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
874 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
875 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
876 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
877 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
878 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
879 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
880 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
881 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
882 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
883 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
884 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
885 * station
886 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
887 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
888 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
889 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
890 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
891 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
892 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
893 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
894 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
895 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
896 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
897 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
898 * hardware queue.
899 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
900 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
901 * is for the whole aggregation.
902 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
903 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
904 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
905 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
906 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
907 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
908 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
909 * off-channel operation.
910 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
911 * (header conversion)
912 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
913 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
914 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
915 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
916 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
917 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
918 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
919 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
920 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
921 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
922 * queue gets full.
923 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
924 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
925 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
926 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
927 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
928 * should kick the MLME state machine.
929 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
930 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
931 * status to user space)
932 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
933 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
934 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
935 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
936 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
937 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
938 * handled properly by the device.
939 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
940 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
941 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
942 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
943 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
944 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
945 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
946 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
947 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
948 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
949 * PS-Poll responses.
950 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
951 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
952 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
953 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
954 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
955 * monitor injection).
956 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
957 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
958 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
959 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
960 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
961 *
962 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
963 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
964 */
965 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
966 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
967 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
968 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
969 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
970 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
971 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
972 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
973 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
974 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
975 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
976 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
977 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
978 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
979 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
980 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
981 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
982 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
983 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
984 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
985 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
986 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
987 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
988 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
989 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
990 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
991 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
992 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
993 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
994 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
995 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
996 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
997 };
998
999 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
1000
1001 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
1002
1003 /**
1004 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
1005 *
1006 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
1007 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
1008 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
1009 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
1010 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
1011 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1012 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1013 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1014 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1015 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1016 * it can be sent out.
1017 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1018 * has already been assigned to this frame.
1019 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1020 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1021 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1022 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1023 * for sequence number assignment
1024 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1025 * which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1026 * operation on the interface.
1027 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1028 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1029 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1030 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1031 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1032 * it's intended for an MLD.
1033 *
1034 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1035 */
1036 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1037 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
1038 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
1039 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
1040 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
1041 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
1042 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
1043 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
1044 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
1045 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
1046 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
1047 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK = BIT(10),
1048 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
1049 };
1050
1051 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
1052 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
1053 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1054 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1055
1056 /**
1057 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1058 *
1059 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1060 *
1061 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1062 */
1063 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1064 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1065 };
1066
1067 /*
1068 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1069 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1070 */
1071 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
1072 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
1073 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
1074 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
1075 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
1076 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
1077 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
1078 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1079
1080 /**
1081 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1082 * Rate Control algorithm.
1083 *
1084 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1085 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1086 *
1087 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1088 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1089 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1090 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1091 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1092 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1093 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1094 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1095 * Greenfield mode.
1096 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1097 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1098 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1099 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
1100 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1101 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1102 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1103 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1104 */
1105 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1106 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1107 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1108 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1109
1110 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1111 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1112 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1113 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1114 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1115 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1116 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1117 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1118 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1119 };
1120
1121
1122 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1123 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1124
1125 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1126 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1127
1128 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1129 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1130
1131 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1132 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1133
1134 /**
1135 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1136 *
1137 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1138 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1139 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1140 *
1141 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1142 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1143 *
1144 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1145 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1146 *
1147 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1148 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1149 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1150 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1151 * information::
1152 *
1153 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1154 *
1155 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1156 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1157 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1158 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1159 * information should then contain::
1160 *
1161 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1162 *
1163 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1164 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1165 */
1166 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1167 s8 idx;
1168 u16 count:5,
1169 flags:11;
1170 } __packed;
1171
1172 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1173
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1174 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1175 {
1176 return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1177 }
1178
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1179 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1180 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1181 {
1182 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1183 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1184 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1185 }
1186
1187 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1188 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1189 {
1190 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1191 }
1192
1193 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1194 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1195 {
1196 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1197 }
1198
1199 /**
1200 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1201 *
1202 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1203 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1204 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1205 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1206 *
1207 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1208 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1209 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1210 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1211 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1212 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1213 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1214 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1215 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1216 * @control: union part for control data
1217 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1218 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1219 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1220 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1221 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1222 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1223 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1224 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1225 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1226 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1227 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1228 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1229 * @pad: padding
1230 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1231 * @status: union part for status data
1232 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1233 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1234 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1235 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1236 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1237 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1238 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1239 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1240 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1241 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1242 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1243 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1244 */
1245 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1246 /* common information */
1247 u32 flags;
1248 u32 band:3,
1249 status_data_idr:1,
1250 status_data:13,
1251 hw_queue:4,
1252 tx_time_est:10;
1253 /* 1 free bit */
1254
1255 union {
1256 struct {
1257 union {
1258 /* rate control */
1259 struct {
1260 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1261 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1262 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1263 u8 use_rts:1;
1264 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1265 u8 short_preamble:1;
1266 u8 skip_table:1;
1267
1268 /* for injection only (bitmap) */
1269 u8 antennas:2;
1270
1271 /* 14 bits free */
1272 };
1273 /* only needed before rate control */
1274 unsigned long jiffies;
1275 };
1276 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1277 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1278 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1279 u32 flags;
1280 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1281 } control;
1282 struct {
1283 u64 cookie;
1284 } ack;
1285 struct {
1286 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1287 s32 ack_signal;
1288 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1289 u8 ampdu_len;
1290 u8 antenna;
1291 u8 pad;
1292 u16 tx_time;
1293 u8 flags;
1294 u8 pad2;
1295 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1296 } status;
1297 struct {
1298 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1299 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1300 u8 pad[4];
1301
1302 void *rate_driver_data[
1303 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1304 };
1305 void *driver_data[
1306 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1307 };
1308 };
1309
1310 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1311 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1312 {
1313 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1314 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1315 */
1316 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1317 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1318 }
1319
1320 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1321 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1322 {
1323 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1324 }
1325
1326 /***
1327 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1328 *
1329 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1330 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1331 *
1332 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1333 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1334 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1335 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1336 * that was used when sending the packet.
1337 */
1338 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1339 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1340 u8 try_count;
1341 u8 tx_power_idx;
1342 };
1343
1344 /**
1345 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1346 *
1347 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1348 * @info: Basic tx status information
1349 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1350 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1351 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1352 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1353 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1354 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1355 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1356 */
1357 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1358 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1359 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1360 struct sk_buff *skb;
1361 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1362 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1363 u8 n_rates;
1364
1365 struct list_head *free_list;
1366 };
1367
1368 /**
1369 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1370 *
1371 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1372 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1373 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1374 *
1375 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1376 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1377 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1378 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1379 */
1380 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1381 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1382 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1383 const u8 *common_ies;
1384 size_t common_ie_len;
1385 };
1386
1387
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1388 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1389 {
1390 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1391 }
1392
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1393 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1394 {
1395 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1396 }
1397
1398 /**
1399 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1400 *
1401 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1402 *
1403 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1404 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1405 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1406 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1407 *
1408 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1409 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1410 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1411 */
1412 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1413 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1414 {
1415 int i;
1416
1417 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1418 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1419 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1420 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1421 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1422 /* clear the rate counts */
1423 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1424 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1425 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1426 }
1427
1428
1429 /**
1430 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1431 *
1432 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1433 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1434 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1435 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1436 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1437 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1438 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1439 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1440 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1441 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1442 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1443 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1444 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1445 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1446 * de-duplication by itself.
1447 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1448 * the frame.
1449 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1450 * the frame.
1451 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1452 * field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1453 * where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1454 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1455 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1456 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1457 * merging.
1458 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1459 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1460 * (including FCS) was received.
1461 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1462 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1463 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1464 * is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1465 * @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1466 * %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1467 * reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1468 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1469 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1470 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1471 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1472 * each A-MPDU
1473 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1474 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1475 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1476 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1477 * on this subframe
1478 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1479 * done by the hardware
1480 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1481 * processing it in any regular way.
1482 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1483 * them for sniffing purposes.
1484 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1485 * monitor interfaces.
1486 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1487 * them for sniffing purposes.
1488 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1489 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1490 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1491 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1492 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1493 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1494 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1495 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1496 * interleaved with other frames.
1497 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1498 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1499 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1500 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1501 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1502 * in the skb.
1503 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1504 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1505 * the first subframe.
1506 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1507 * be done in the hardware.
1508 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1509 * frame
1510 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1511 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1512 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1513 *
1514 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1515 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1516 * - DATA3_CODING
1517 * - DATA5_GI
1518 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1519 * - DATA6_NSTS
1520 * - DATA3_STBC
1521 *
1522 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1523 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1524 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1525 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1526 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1527 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1528 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1529 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1530 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1531 * hardware or driver)
1532 */
1533 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1534 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1535 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1536 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(2),
1537 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1538 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1539 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1540 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1541 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64 = BIT(7),
1542 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1543 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1544 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1545 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1546 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1547 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1548 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1549 /* one free bit at 15 */
1550 RX_FLAG_MACTIME = BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1551 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = 1 << 16,
1552 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = 2 << 16,
1553 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = 3 << 16,
1554 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1555 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1556 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20),
1557 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1558 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1559 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1560 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1561 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1562 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1563 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1564 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1565 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1566 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1567 };
1568
1569 /**
1570 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1571 *
1572 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1573 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1574 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1575 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1576 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1577 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1578 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1579 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1580 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1581 */
1582 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1583 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1584 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1585 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1586 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1587 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1588 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1589 };
1590
1591 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1592
1593 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1594 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1595 RX_ENC_HT,
1596 RX_ENC_VHT,
1597 RX_ENC_HE,
1598 RX_ENC_EHT,
1599 };
1600
1601 /**
1602 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1603 *
1604 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1605 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1606 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1607 *
1608 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1609 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1610 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1611 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1612 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1613 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1614 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1615 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1616 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1617 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1618 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1619 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1620 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1621 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1622 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1623 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1624 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1625 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1626 * values were filled.
1627 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1628 * support dB or unspecified units)
1629 * @antenna: antenna used
1630 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1631 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1632 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1633 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1634 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1635 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1636 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1637 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1638 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1639 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1640 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1641 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1642 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1643 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1644 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1645 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1646 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1647 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1648 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1649 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1650 * @link_valid.
1651 */
1652 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1653 u64 mactime;
1654 union {
1655 u64 boottime_ns;
1656 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1657 };
1658 u32 device_timestamp;
1659 u32 ampdu_reference;
1660 u32 flag;
1661 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1662 u8 enc_flags;
1663 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1664 union {
1665 struct {
1666 u8 he_ru:3;
1667 u8 he_gi:2;
1668 u8 he_dcm:1;
1669 };
1670 struct {
1671 u8 ru:4;
1672 u8 gi:2;
1673 } eht;
1674 };
1675 u8 rate_idx;
1676 u8 nss;
1677 u8 rx_flags;
1678 u8 band;
1679 u8 antenna;
1680 s8 signal;
1681 u8 chains;
1682 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1683 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1684 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1685 };
1686
1687 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1688 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1689 {
1690 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1691 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1692 }
1693
1694 /**
1695 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1696 *
1697 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1698 *
1699 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1700 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1701 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1702 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1703 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1704 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1705 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1706 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1707 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1708 * for more.
1709 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1710 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1711 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1712 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1713 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1714 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1715 * operating channel.
1716 */
1717 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1718 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1719 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1720 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1721 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1722 };
1723
1724
1725 /**
1726 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1727 *
1728 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1729 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1730 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1731 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1732 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1733 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1734 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1735 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1736 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1737 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1738 */
1739 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1740 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1741 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1742 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1743 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1744 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1745 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1746 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1747 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1748 };
1749
1750 /**
1751 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1752 *
1753 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1754 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1755 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1756 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1757 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1758 */
1759 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1760 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1761 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1762 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1763 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1764
1765 /* keep last */
1766 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1767 };
1768
1769 /**
1770 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1771 *
1772 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1773 *
1774 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1775 *
1776 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1777 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1778 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1779 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1780 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1781 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1782 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1783 *
1784 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1785 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1786 *
1787 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1788 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1789 *
1790 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1791 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1792 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1793 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1794 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1795 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1796 *
1797 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1798 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1799 * configured for an HT channel.
1800 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1801 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1802 */
1803 struct ieee80211_conf {
1804 u32 flags;
1805 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1806
1807 u16 listen_interval;
1808 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1809
1810 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1811
1812 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1813 bool radar_enabled;
1814 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1815 };
1816
1817 /**
1818 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1819 *
1820 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1821 * operation.
1822 *
1823 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1824 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1825 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1826 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1827 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1828 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1829 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1830 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1831 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1832 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1833 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1834 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1835 * channel, expressed in TU.
1836 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1837 */
1838 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1839 u64 timestamp;
1840 u32 device_timestamp;
1841 bool block_tx;
1842 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1843 u8 count;
1844 u8 link_id;
1845 u32 delay;
1846 };
1847
1848 /**
1849 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1850 *
1851 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1852 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1853 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1854 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1855 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1856 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1857 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1858 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1859 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1860 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1861 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1862 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1863 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1864 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1865 * enabled for the interface.
1866 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1867 * operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1868 * the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1869 * handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1870 * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
1871 * be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
1872 * opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
1873 */
1874 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1875 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1876 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1877 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1878 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1879 IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE = BIT(4),
1880 IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW = BIT(5),
1881 IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC = BIT(6),
1882 };
1883
1884
1885 /**
1886 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1887 *
1888 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1889 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1890 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1891 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1892 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1893 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1894 * mac80211.
1895 */
1896
1897 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1898 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1899 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1900 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1901 };
1902
1903 /**
1904 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1905 * @assoc: association status
1906 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1907 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1908 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1909 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1910 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1911 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1912 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1913 * P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1914 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1915 * Figure 9-1001k
1916 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1917 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1918 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1919 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1920 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1921 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1922 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1923 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1924 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1925 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1926 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1927 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1928 * your driver/device needs to do.
1929 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1930 * (station mode only)
1931 */
1932 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1933 /* association related data */
1934 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1935 bool ibss_creator;
1936 bool ps;
1937 u16 aid;
1938 u16 eml_cap;
1939 u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1940 u16 mld_capa_op;
1941
1942 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1943 int arp_addr_cnt;
1944 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1945 size_t ssid_len;
1946 bool s1g;
1947 bool idle;
1948 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1949 };
1950
1951 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1952
1953 /**
1954 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1955 *
1956 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1957 * this TID is not included.
1958 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1959 * TID is not included.
1960 * @valid: info is valid or not.
1961 */
1962 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1963 u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1964 u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1965 bool valid;
1966 };
1967
1968 /**
1969 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1970 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1971 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1972 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1973 */
1974 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1975 NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1976 NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1977 NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1978 };
1979
1980 /**
1981 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1982 *
1983 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1984 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1985 *
1986 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1987 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1988 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1989 * or the BSS we're associated to
1990 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1991 * indexed by link ID
1992 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1993 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1994 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1995 * API calls meant for that purpose.
1996 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1997 * due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1998 * 0 for non-MLO.
1999 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
2000 * suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
2001 * future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
2002 * 0 for non-MLO.
2003 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
2004 * see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
2005 * @addr: address of this interface
2006 * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
2007 * passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
2008 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
2009 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
2010 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
2011 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
2012 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
2013 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
2014 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
2015 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2016 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2017 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2018 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2019 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2020 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2021 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2022 * restrictions.
2023 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2024 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2025 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2026 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2027 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2028 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2029 * interface.
2030 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2031 * for this interface.
2032 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2033 * sizeof(void \*).
2034 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2035 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2036 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2037 */
2038 struct ieee80211_vif {
2039 enum nl80211_iftype type;
2040 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2041 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2042 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2043 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2044 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2045 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2046 bool addr_valid;
2047 bool p2p;
2048
2049 u8 cab_queue;
2050 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2051
2052 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2053
2054 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2055 u32 driver_flags;
2056 u32 offload_flags;
2057
2058 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2059 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2060 #endif
2061
2062 bool probe_req_reg;
2063 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2064
2065 /* must be last */
2066 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2067 };
2068
2069 /**
2070 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2071 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2072 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2073 */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2074 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2075 {
2076 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2077 }
2078
2079 /**
2080 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2081 * @vif: the vif
2082 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2083 */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2084 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2085 {
2086 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2087 return vif->valid_links != 0;
2088 }
2089
2090 /**
2091 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2092 * @vif: the vif
2093 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2094 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2095 * the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2096 */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2097 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2098 unsigned int link_id)
2099 {
2100 if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2101 return link_id == 0;
2102 return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2103 }
2104
2105 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
2106 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
2107 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2108 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2109 (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2110
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2111 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2112 {
2113 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2114 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2115 #endif
2116 return false;
2117 }
2118
2119 /**
2120 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2121 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2122 *
2123 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2124 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2125 *
2126 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2127 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2128 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2129 */
2130 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2131
2132 /**
2133 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2134 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2135 *
2136 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2137 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2138 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2139 *
2140 * Return: pointer to the wdev
2141 */
2142 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2143
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2144 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2145 {
2146 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2147 }
2148
2149 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
2150 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2151 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2152
2153 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
2154 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2155 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2156
2157 /**
2158 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2159 *
2160 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2161 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2162 *
2163 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2164 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2165 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2166 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2167 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2168 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2169 * generation in software.
2170 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2171 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2172 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2173 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2174 * (MFP) to be done in software.
2175 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2176 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2177 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2178 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2179 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2180 * MIC.
2181 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2182 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2183 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2184 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2185 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2186 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2187 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2188 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2189 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2190 * only for management frames (MFP).
2191 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2192 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2193 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2194 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2195 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2196 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2197 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2198 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2199 * for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2200 * number generation only
2201 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2202 * (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2203 */
2204 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2205 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2206 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2207 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2208 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2209 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2210 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2211 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2212 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2213 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2214 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2215 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2216 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(11),
2217 };
2218
2219 /**
2220 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2221 *
2222 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2223 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2224 *
2225 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2226 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2227 * encrypted in hardware.
2228 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2229 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2230 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2231 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2232 * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
2233 * @keylen: key material length
2234 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2235 * data block:
2236 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2237 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2238 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2239 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2240 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2241 * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
2242 */
2243 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2244 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2245 u32 cipher;
2246 u8 icv_len;
2247 u8 iv_len;
2248 u8 hw_key_idx;
2249 s8 keyidx;
2250 u16 flags;
2251 s8 link_id;
2252 u8 keylen;
2253 u8 key[];
2254 };
2255
2256 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2257
2258 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2259 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2260
2261 /**
2262 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2263 *
2264 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2265 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2266 * reverse order than in packet)
2267 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2268 * reverse order than in packet)
2269 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2270 * reverse order than in packet)
2271 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2272 * reverse order than in packet)
2273 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2274 */
2275 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2276 union {
2277 struct {
2278 u32 iv32;
2279 u16 iv16;
2280 } tkip;
2281 struct {
2282 u8 pn[6];
2283 } ccmp;
2284 struct {
2285 u8 pn[6];
2286 } aes_cmac;
2287 struct {
2288 u8 pn[6];
2289 } aes_gmac;
2290 struct {
2291 u8 pn[6];
2292 } gcmp;
2293 struct {
2294 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2295 u8 seq_len;
2296 } hw;
2297 };
2298 };
2299
2300 /**
2301 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2302 *
2303 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2304 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2305 *
2306 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2307 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2308 */
2309 enum set_key_cmd {
2310 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2311 };
2312
2313 /**
2314 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2315 *
2316 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2317 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2318 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2319 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2320 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2321 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2322 */
2323 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2324 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2325 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2326 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2327 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2328 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2329 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2330 };
2331
2332 /**
2333 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2334 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2335 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2336 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2337 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2338 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2339 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2340 *
2341 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2342 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2343 */
2344 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2345 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2346 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2347 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2348 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2349 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2350 };
2351
2352 #define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320
2353
2354 /**
2355 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2356 *
2357 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2358 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2359 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2360 */
2361 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2362 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2363 struct {
2364 s8 idx;
2365 u8 count;
2366 u8 count_cts;
2367 u8 count_rts;
2368 u16 flags;
2369 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2370 };
2371
2372 /**
2373 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2374 *
2375 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2376 *
2377 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2378 * to the STA.
2379 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2380 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2381 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2382 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2383 * per peer TPC.
2384 */
2385 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2386 s16 power;
2387 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2388 };
2389
2390 /**
2391 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2392 *
2393 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2394 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2395 *
2396 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2397 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2398 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2399 *
2400 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2401 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2402 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2403 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2404 *
2405 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2406 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2407 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2408 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2409 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2410 */
2411 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2412 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2413
2414 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2415 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2416 };
2417
2418 /**
2419 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2420 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2421 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2422 *
2423 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2424 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2425 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2426 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2427 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2428 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2429 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2430 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2431 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2432 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2433 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2434 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2435 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities of this STA
2436 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2437 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2438 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2439 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2440 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2441 * the station moves to associated state.
2442 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2443 *
2444 */
2445 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2446 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2447
2448 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2449 u8 link_id;
2450 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2451
2452 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2453 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2454 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2455 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2456 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2457 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2458 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
2459
2460 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2461
2462 u8 rx_nss;
2463 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2464 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2465 };
2466
2467 /**
2468 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2469 *
2470 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2471 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2472 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2473 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2474 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2475 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2476 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2477 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2478 *
2479 * @addr: MAC address
2480 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2481 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2482 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2483 * Can be modified by driver.
2484 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2485 * otherwise always false)
2486 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2487 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2488 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2489 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2490 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2491 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2492 * @rates: rate control selection table
2493 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2494 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2495 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2496 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2497 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2498 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2499 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2500 * unlimited.
2501 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities of this MLO station
2502 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2503 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2504 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2505 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2506 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2507 * is used for non-data frames
2508 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2509 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2510 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2511 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2512 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2513 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2514 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2515 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2516 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2517 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2518 * by the AP.
2519 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2520 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2521 */
2522 struct ieee80211_sta {
2523 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2524 u16 aid;
2525 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2526 bool wme;
2527 u8 uapsd_queues;
2528 u8 max_sp;
2529 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2530 bool tdls;
2531 bool tdls_initiator;
2532 bool mfp;
2533 bool mlo;
2534 bool spp_amsdu;
2535 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2536 u16 eml_cap;
2537
2538 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2539
2540 bool support_p2p_ps;
2541
2542 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2543
2544 u16 valid_links;
2545 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2546 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2547
2548 /* must be last */
2549 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2550 };
2551
2552 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2553 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2554 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2555 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2556 {
2557 return true;
2558 }
2559 #endif
2560
2561 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2562 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2563 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2564
2565 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2566 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2567 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2568
2569 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2570 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2571 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2572 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2573 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2574
2575 /**
2576 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2577 *
2578 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2579 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2580 *
2581 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2582 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2583 */
2584 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2585 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2586 };
2587
2588 /**
2589 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2590 *
2591 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2592 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2593 */
2594 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2595 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2596 };
2597
2598 /**
2599 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2600 *
2601 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2602 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2603 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2604 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2605 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2606 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2607 *
2608 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2609 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2610 */
2611 struct ieee80211_txq {
2612 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2613 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2614 u8 tid;
2615 u8 ac;
2616
2617 /* must be last */
2618 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2619 };
2620
2621 /**
2622 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2623 *
2624 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2625 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2626 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2627 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2628 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2629 *
2630 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2631 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2632 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2633 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2634 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2635 * algorithm.
2636 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2637 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2638 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2639 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2640 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2641 * CCK frames.
2642 *
2643 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2644 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2645 * the FCS at the end.
2646 *
2647 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2648 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2649 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2650 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2651 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2652 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2653 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2654 *
2655 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2656 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2657 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2658 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2659 *
2660 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2661 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2662 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2663 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2664 *
2665 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2666 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2667 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2668 *
2669 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2670 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2671 *
2672 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2673 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2674 *
2675 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2676 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2677 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2678 *
2679 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2680 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2681 *
2682 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2683 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2684 *
2685 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2686 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2687 * the stack.
2688 *
2689 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2690 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2691 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2692 *
2693 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2694 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2695 * dtim_period).
2696 *
2697 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2698 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2699 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2700 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2701 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2702 * only in that case.
2703 *
2704 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2705 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2706 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2707 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2708 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2709 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2710 *
2711 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2712 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2713 * software.
2714 *
2715 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2716 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2717 * active interfaces.
2718 *
2719 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2720 * of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2721 * This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2722 * channels.
2723 *
2724 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2725 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2726 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2727 *
2728 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2729 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2730 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2731 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2732 * supported cipher suites.
2733 *
2734 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2735 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2736 * for frames.
2737 *
2738 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2739 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2740 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2741 * control for more details.
2742 *
2743 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2744 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2745 *
2746 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2747 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2748 * is supported.
2749 *
2750 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2751 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2752 *
2753 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2754 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2755 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2756 *
2757 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2758 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2759 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2760 * CSA frame.
2761 *
2762 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2763 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2764 *
2765 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2766 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2767 *
2768 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2769 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2770 *
2771 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2772 * within A-MPDU.
2773 *
2774 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2775 * for sent beacons.
2776 *
2777 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2778 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2779 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2780 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2781 *
2782 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2783 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2784 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2785 * timeout.
2786 *
2787 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2788 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2789 *
2790 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2791 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2792 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2793 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2794 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2795 *
2796 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2797 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2798 *
2799 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2800 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2801 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2802 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2803 *
2804 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2805 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2806 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2807 *
2808 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2809 * TDLS links.
2810 *
2811 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2812 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2813 *
2814 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2815 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2816 *
2817 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2818 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2819 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2820 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2821 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2822 *
2823 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2824 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2825 * TXQs to start with.
2826 *
2827 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2828 * length in tx status information
2829 *
2830 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2831 *
2832 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2833 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2834 *
2835 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2836 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2837 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2838 *
2839 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2840 * offload
2841 *
2842 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2843 * offload
2844 *
2845 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2846 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2847 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2848 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2849 * the stack.
2850 *
2851 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2852 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2853 *
2854 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2855 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2856 *
2857 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2858 * and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2859 *
2860 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2861 * no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2862 * implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2863 * link is switching.
2864 *
2865 * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
2866 * but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
2867 * HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
2868 * testing.
2869 *
2870 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2871 */
2872 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2873 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2874 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2875 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2876 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2877 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2878 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2879 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2880 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2881 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2882 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2883 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2884 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2885 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2886 IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
2887 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2888 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2889 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2890 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2891 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2892 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2893 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2894 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2895 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2896 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2897 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2898 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2899 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2900 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2901 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2902 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2903 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2904 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2905 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2906 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2907 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2908 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2909 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2910 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2911 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2912 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2913 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2914 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2915 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2916 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2917 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2918 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2919 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2920 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2921 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2922 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2923 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2924 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2925 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2926 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2927 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2928 IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2929 IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
2930
2931 /* keep last, obviously */
2932 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2933 };
2934
2935 /**
2936 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2937 *
2938 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2939 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2940 *
2941 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2942 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2943 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2944 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2945 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2946 *
2947 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2948 *
2949 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2950 * along with this structure.
2951 *
2952 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2953 *
2954 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2955 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2956 *
2957 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2958 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2959 *
2960 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2961 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2962 *
2963 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2964 * that HW supports
2965 *
2966 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2967 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2968 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2969 *
2970 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2971 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2972 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2973 *
2974 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2975 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2976 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2977 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2978 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2979 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2980 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2981 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2982 *
2983 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2984 * can handle.
2985 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2986 * the hw can report back.
2987 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2988 *
2989 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2990 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2991 * aggregation.
2992 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2993 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2994 * it shouldn't be set.
2995 *
2996 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2997 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2998 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2999 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
3000 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
3001 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
3002 *
3003 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
3004 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
3005 *
3006 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
3007 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
3008 *
3009 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
3010 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
3011 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
3012 * adding _BW is supported today.
3013 *
3014 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
3015 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
3016 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
3017 *
3018 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
3019 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
3020 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
3021 * device_timestamp.
3022 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3023 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3024 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3025 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3026 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3027 *
3028 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3029 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3030 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3031 *
3032 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3033 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3034 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3035 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3036 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3037 * neither enabled.
3038 *
3039 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3040 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3041 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3042 *
3043 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3044 * device.
3045 *
3046 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3047 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3048 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3049 *
3050 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3051 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3052 *
3053 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3054 *
3055 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3056 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3057 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3058 *
3059 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3060 */
3061 struct ieee80211_hw {
3062 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3063 struct wiphy *wiphy;
3064 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3065 void *priv;
3066 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3067 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3068 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3069 int vif_data_size;
3070 int sta_data_size;
3071 int chanctx_data_size;
3072 int txq_data_size;
3073 u16 queues;
3074 u16 max_listen_interval;
3075 s8 max_signal;
3076 u8 max_rates;
3077 u8 max_report_rates;
3078 u8 max_rate_tries;
3079 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3080 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3081 u8 max_tx_fragments;
3082 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3083 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3084 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3085 struct {
3086 int units_pos;
3087 s16 accuracy;
3088 } radiotap_timestamp;
3089 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3090 u8 uapsd_queues;
3091 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3092 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3093 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3094 u8 weight_multiplier;
3095 u32 max_mtu;
3096 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3097 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3098 };
3099
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3100 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3101 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3102 {
3103 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3104 }
3105 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3106
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3107 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3108 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3109 {
3110 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3111 }
3112 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3113
3114 /**
3115 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3116 *
3117 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3118 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3119 */
3120 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3121 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3122
3123 /* Keep last */
3124 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3125 };
3126
3127 /**
3128 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3129 *
3130 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3131 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3132 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3133 * @status: channel-switch response status
3134 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3135 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3136 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3137 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3138 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3139 */
3140 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3141 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3142 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3143 u8 action_code;
3144 u32 status;
3145 u32 timestamp;
3146 u16 switch_time;
3147 u16 switch_timeout;
3148 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3149 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3150 };
3151
3152 /**
3153 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3154 *
3155 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3156 *
3157 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3158 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3159 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3160 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3161 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3162 *
3163 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3164 */
3165 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3166
3167 /**
3168 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3169 *
3170 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3171 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3172 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3173 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3174 {
3175 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3176 }
3177
3178 /**
3179 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3180 *
3181 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3182 * @addr: the address to set
3183 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3184 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3185 {
3186 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3187 }
3188
3189 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3190 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3191 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3192 {
3193 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3194 return NULL;
3195
3196 if (c->band >= NUM_NL80211_BANDS)
3197 return NULL;
3198
3199 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3200 }
3201
3202 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3203 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3204 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3205 {
3206 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3207 return NULL;
3208 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3209 }
3210
3211 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3212 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3213 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3214 {
3215 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3216 return NULL;
3217 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3218 }
3219
3220 /**
3221 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3222 * @hw: the hardware
3223 * @skb: the skb
3224 *
3225 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3226 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3227 */
3228 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3229
3230 /**
3231 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3232 * @hw: the hardware
3233 * @skbs: the skbs
3234 *
3235 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3236 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3237 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3238 * relevant locks to use it.
3239 */
3240 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3241 struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3242
3243 /**
3244 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3245 *
3246 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3247 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3248 *
3249 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3250 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3251 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3252 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3253 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3254 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3255 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3256 *
3257 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3258 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3259 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3260 *
3261 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3262 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3263 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3264 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3265 *
3266 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3267 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3268 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3269 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3270 *
3271 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3272 *
3273 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3274 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3275 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3276 * based on the receive flags.
3277 *
3278 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3279 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3280 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3281 * keys.
3282 *
3283 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3284 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3285 * handler.
3286 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3287 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3288 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3289 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3290 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3291 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3292 *
3293 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3294 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3295 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3296 *
3297 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3298 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3299 * requirements:
3300 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3301 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3302 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3303 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3304 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3305 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3306 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3307 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3308 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3309 */
3310
3311 /**
3312 * DOC: Powersave support
3313 *
3314 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3315 *
3316 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3317 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3318 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3319 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3320 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3321 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3322 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3323 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3324 *
3325 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3326 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3327 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3328 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3329 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3330 *
3331 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3332 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3333 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3334 *
3335 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3336 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3337 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3338 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3339 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3340 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3341 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3342 *
3343 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3344 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3345 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3346 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3347 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3348 * periods.
3349 *
3350 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3351 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3352 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3353 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3354 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3355 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3356 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3357 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3358 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3359 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3360 *
3361 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3362 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3363 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3364 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3365 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3366 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3367 *
3368 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3369 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3370 */
3371
3372 /**
3373 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3374 *
3375 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3376 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3377 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3378 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3379 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3380 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3381 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3382 *
3383 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3384 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3385 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3386 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3387 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3388 *
3389 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3390 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3391 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3392 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3393 *
3394 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3395 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3396 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3397 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3398 *
3399 * - a list of information element IDs
3400 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3401 *
3402 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3403 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3404 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3405 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3406 * vendor information elements.
3407 *
3408 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3409 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3410 *
3411 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3412 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3413 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3414 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3415 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3416 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3417 *
3418 *
3419 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3420 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3421 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3422 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3423 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3424 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3425 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3426 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3427 *
3428 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3429 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3430 * signal strength threshold checking.
3431 */
3432
3433 /**
3434 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3435 *
3436 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3437 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3438 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3439 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3440 *
3441 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3442 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3443 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3444 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3445 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3446 * hardware flags.
3447 *
3448 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3449 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3450 * turned off otherwise.
3451 *
3452 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3453 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3454 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3455 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3456 */
3457
3458 /**
3459 * DOC: Frame filtering
3460 *
3461 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3462 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3463 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3464 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3465 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3466 *
3467 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3468 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3469 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3470 *
3471 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3472 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3473 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3474 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3475 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3476 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3477 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3478 *
3479 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3480 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3481 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3482 * or dropped.
3483 *
3484 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3485 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3486 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3487 * the flag, but not clear it.
3488 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3489 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3490 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3491 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3492 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3493 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3494 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3495 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3496 */
3497
3498 /**
3499 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3500 *
3501 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3502 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3503 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3504 *
3505 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3506 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3507 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3508 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3509 * the driver code.
3510 *
3511 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3512 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3513 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3514 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3515 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3516 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3517 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3518 *
3519 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3520 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3521 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3522 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3523 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3524 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3525 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3526 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3527 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3528 * @sta_notify callback.
3529 *
3530 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3531 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3532 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3533 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3534 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3535 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3536 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3537 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3538 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3539 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3540 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3541 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3542 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3543 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3544 *
3545 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3546 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3547 *
3548 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3549 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3550 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3551 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3552 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3553 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3554 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3555 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3556 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3557 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3558 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3559 *
3560 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3561 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3562 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3563 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3564 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3565 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3566 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3567 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3568 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3569 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3570 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3571 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3572 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3573 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3574 *
3575 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3576 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3577 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3578 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3579 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3580 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3581 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3582 *
3583 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3584 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3585 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3586 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3587 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3588 *
3589 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3590 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3591 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3592 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3593 */
3594
3595 /**
3596 * DOC: HW queue control
3597 *
3598 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3599 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3600 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3601 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3602 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3603 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3604 *
3605 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3606 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3607 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3608 *
3609 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3610 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3611 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3612 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3613 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3614 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3615 * the hardware queue.
3616 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3617 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3618 *
3619 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3620 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3621 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3622 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3623 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3624 *
3625 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3626 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3627 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3628 * off-channel queue: 9
3629 *
3630 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3631 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3632 *
3633 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3634 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3635 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3636 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3637 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3638 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3639 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3640 *
3641 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3642 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3643 *
3644 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3645 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3646 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3647 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3648 */
3649
3650 /**
3651 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3652 *
3653 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3654 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3655 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3656 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3657 *
3658 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3659 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3660 * multicast address.
3661 *
3662 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3663 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3664 *
3665 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3666 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3667 *
3668 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3669 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3670 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3671 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3672 * honour this flag if possible.
3673 *
3674 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3675 * station
3676 *
3677 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3678 *
3679 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3680 *
3681 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3682 *
3683 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3684 */
3685 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3686 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3687 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3688 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3689 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3690 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3691 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3692 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3693 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3694 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3695 };
3696
3697 /**
3698 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3699 *
3700 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3701 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3702 *
3703 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3704 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3705 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3706 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3707 *
3708 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3709 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3710 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3711 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3712 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3713 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3714 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3715 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3716 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3717 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3718 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3719 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3720 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3721 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3722 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3723 * session is gone and removes the station.
3724 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3725 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3726 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3727 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3728 */
3729 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3730 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3731 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3732 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3733 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3734 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3735 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3736 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3737 };
3738
3739 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3740 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3741
3742 /**
3743 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3744 *
3745 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3746 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3747 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3748 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3749 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3750 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3751 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3752 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3753 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3754 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3755 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3756 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3757 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3758 */
3759 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3760 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3761 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3762 u16 tid;
3763 u16 ssn;
3764 u16 buf_size;
3765 bool amsdu;
3766 u16 timeout;
3767 };
3768
3769 /**
3770 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3771 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3772 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3773 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3774 */
3775 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3776 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3777 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3778 };
3779
3780 /**
3781 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3782 *
3783 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3784 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3785 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3786 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3787 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3788 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3789 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3790 * the peer.
3791 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3792 * by the peer
3793 */
3794 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3795 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3796 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3797 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3798 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3799 };
3800
3801 /**
3802 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3803 *
3804 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3805 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3806 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3807 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3808 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3809 *
3810 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3811 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3812 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3813 */
3814 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3815 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3816 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3817 };
3818
3819 /**
3820 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3821 *
3822 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3823 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3824 *
3825 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3826 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3827 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3828 * of wowlan configuration)
3829 */
3830 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3831 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3832 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3833 };
3834
3835 /**
3836 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3837 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3838 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3839 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3840 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3841 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3842 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3843 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3844 * while just having been associated
3845 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3846 * 0 for a non-MLO connection.
3847 */
3848 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3849 u16 duration;
3850 u16 subtype;
3851 u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3852 int link_id;
3853 };
3854
3855 /**
3856 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3857 *
3858 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3859 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3860 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3861 *
3862 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3863 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3864 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3865 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3866 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3867 * Must be atomic.
3868 *
3869 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3870 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3871 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3872 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3873 * or zero.
3874 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3875 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3876 * is added.
3877 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3878 *
3879 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3880 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3881 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3882 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3883 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3884 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3885 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3886 *
3887 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3888 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3889 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3890 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3891 * reconfigured at resume time.
3892 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3893 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3894 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3895 * must return 1 from this function.
3896 *
3897 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3898 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3899 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3900 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3901 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3902 *
3903 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3904 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3905 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3906 * in suspend().
3907 *
3908 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3909 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3910 * and @stop must be implemented.
3911 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3912 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3913 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3914 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3915 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3916 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3917 *
3918 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3919 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3920 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3921 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3922 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3923 *
3924 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3925 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3926 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3927 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3928 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3929 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3930 * MAC address of the device going away.
3931 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3932 *
3933 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3934 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3935 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3936 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3937 *
3938 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3939 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3940 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3941 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3942 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3943 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3944 * can sleep.
3945 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3946 * are not implemented.
3947 *
3948 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3949 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3950 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3951 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3952 * The callback can sleep.
3953 *
3954 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3955 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3956 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3957 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3958 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3959 * non-MLO connections.
3960 * The callback can sleep.
3961 *
3962 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3963 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3964 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3965 *
3966 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3967 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3968 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3969 *
3970 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3971 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3972 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3973 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3974 * which flags are changed.
3975 * This callback can sleep.
3976 *
3977 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3978 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3979 *
3980 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3981 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3982 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3983 * is enabled.
3984 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3985 * The callback can sleep.
3986 *
3987 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3988 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3989 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3990 * The callback must be atomic.
3991 *
3992 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3993 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3994 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3995 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3996 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3997 *
3998 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3999 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
4000 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
4001 *
4002 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
4003 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
4004 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
4005 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
4006 * that power save is disabled.
4007 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
4008 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
4009 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
4010 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
4011 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
4012 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
4013 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
4014 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
4015 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
4016 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
4017 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
4018 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
4019 * The callback can sleep.
4020 *
4021 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
4022 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
4023 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
4024 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
4025 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4026 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4027 * The callback can sleep.
4028 *
4029 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4030 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
4031 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4032 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4033 *
4034 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4035 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4036 *
4037 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4038 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4039 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4040 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4041 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4042 *
4043 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4044 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4045 * this notification.
4046 * The callback can sleep.
4047 *
4048 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4049 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
4050 * The callback can sleep.
4051 *
4052 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4053 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4054 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4055 * The callback must be atomic.
4056 *
4057 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4058 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4059 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4060 * should be set as well.
4061 * The callback can sleep.
4062 *
4063 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4064 * The callback can sleep.
4065 *
4066 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4067 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4068 *
4069 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4070 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4071 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4072 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4073 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4074 * This callback can sleep.
4075 *
4076 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4077 * directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4078 * CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4079 *
4080 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4081 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4082 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4083 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4084 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4085 *
4086 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4087 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4088 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4089 * callback can sleep.
4090 *
4091 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4092 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4093 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4094 * callback can sleep.
4095 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4096 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4097 *
4098 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4099 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4100 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4101 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4102 *
4103 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4104 * power for the station.
4105 * This callback can sleep.
4106 *
4107 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4108 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4109 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4110 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4111 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4112 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4113 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4114 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4115 * The callback can sleep.
4116 *
4117 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4118 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4119 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4120 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4121 * in @sta_state.
4122 * The callback can sleep.
4123 *
4124 * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4125 * be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4126 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4127 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4128 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4129 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4130 * Must be atomic.
4131 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4132 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4133 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4134 *
4135 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4136 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4137 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4138 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4139 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4140 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4141 * The callback can sleep.
4142 *
4143 * @link_sta_statistics: Get link statistics for this station. For example with
4144 * beacon filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be
4145 * accurate, so let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can
4146 * fill most of the values (indicating which by setting the filled
4147 * bitmap), but not all of them make sense - see the source for which
4148 * ones are possible.
4149 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4150 * The callback can sleep.
4151 *
4152 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4153 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4154 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
4155 * The callback can sleep.
4156 *
4157 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4158 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4159 * required function.
4160 * The callback can sleep.
4161 *
4162 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4163 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4164 * required function.
4165 * The callback can sleep.
4166 *
4167 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4168 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4169 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4170 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4171 * The callback can sleep.
4172 *
4173 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4174 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4175 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4176 * TSF synchronization.
4177 * The callback can sleep.
4178 *
4179 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4180 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4181 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4182 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4183 * The callback can sleep.
4184 *
4185 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4186 *
4187 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4188 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4189 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4190 * The callback can sleep.
4191 *
4192 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4193 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4194 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4195 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4196 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4197 *
4198 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4199 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4200 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4201 *
4202 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4203 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4204 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4205 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4206 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4207 * Note that vif can be NULL.
4208 * The callback can sleep.
4209 *
4210 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4211 * the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4212 * The callback can sleep.
4213 *
4214 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4215 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4216 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4217 * completion of the channel switch.
4218 *
4219 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4220 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4221 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4222 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4223 *
4224 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4225 *
4226 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4227 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4228 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4229 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4230 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4231 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4232 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4233 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4234 * must be accepted in this case.
4235 * This callback may sleep.
4236 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4237 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4238 *
4239 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4240 *
4241 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4242 *
4243 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4244 * queues before entering power save.
4245 *
4246 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4247 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4248 * The callback can sleep.
4249 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4250 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4251 * The callback must be atomic.
4252 *
4253 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4254 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4255 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4256 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4257 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4258 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4259 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4260 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4261 * more-data bit must always be set.
4262 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4263 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4264 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4265 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4266 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4267 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4268 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4269 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4270 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4271 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4272 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4273 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4274 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4275 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4276 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4277 * This callback must be atomic.
4278 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4279 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4280 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4281 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4282 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4283 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4284 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4285 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4286 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4287 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4288 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4289 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4290 * This callback must be atomic.
4291 *
4292 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4293 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4294 * expected to return a static value.
4295 *
4296 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4297 *
4298 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4299 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4300 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4301 * expected to return a static value.
4302 *
4303 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4304 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4305 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4306 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4307 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4308 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4309 * management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4310 * to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4311 * able to synchronize with the GO.
4312 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4313 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4314 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4315 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4316 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4317 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4318 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4319 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4320 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4321 * Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
4322 * example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
4323 *
4324 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4325 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4326 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4327 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4328 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4329 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4330 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4331 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4332 *
4333 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4334 * This callback may sleep.
4335 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4336 * This callback may sleep.
4337 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4338 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4339 * channel context with different settings
4340 * This callback may sleep.
4341 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4342 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4343 * This callback may sleep.
4344 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4345 * unbound from vif.
4346 * This callback may sleep.
4347 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4348 * another, as specified in the list of
4349 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4350 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4351 * This callback may sleep.
4352 *
4353 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4354 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4355 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4356 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4357 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4358 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4359 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4360 *
4361 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4362 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4363 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4364 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4365 * This callback may sleep.
4366 *
4367 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4368 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4369 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4370 *
4371 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4372 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4373 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4374 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4375 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4376 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4377 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4378 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4379 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4380 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4381 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4382 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4383 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4384 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4385 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4386 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4387 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4388 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4389 * when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4390 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4391 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4392 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4393 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4394 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4395 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4396 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4397 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4398 *
4399 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4400 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4401 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4402 *
4403 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4404 * and hardware limits.
4405 *
4406 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4407 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4408 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4409 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4410 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4411 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4412 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4413 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4414 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4415 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4416 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4417 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4418 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4419 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4420 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4421 * the function call.
4422 *
4423 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4424 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4425 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4426 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4427 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4428 *
4429 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4430 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4431 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4432 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4433 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4434 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4435 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4436 * changed parameters.
4437 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4438 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4439 * this call.
4440 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4441 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4442 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4443 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4444 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4445 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4446 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4447 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4448 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4449 *
4450 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4451 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4452 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4453 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4454 * This callback may sleep.
4455 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4456 * This callback may sleep.
4457 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4458 * 4-address mode
4459 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4460 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4461 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4462 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4463 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4464 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4465 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4466 * twt structure.
4467 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4468 * from the peer.
4469 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4470 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4471 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4472 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4473 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4474 * radar channel.
4475 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4476 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4477 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4478 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4479 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4480 * supported by the driver.
4481 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4482 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4483 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4484 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4485 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4486 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4487 * Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
4488 * will be ignored in a removal only case.
4489 * This callback can sleep.
4490 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4491 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4492 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4493 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4494 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4495 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4496 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4497 * that.
4498 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4499 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4500 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4501 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4502 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4503 * if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4504 * If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4505 * modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4506 * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4507 * drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4508 * the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4509 * interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4510 * implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4511 * &enum nl80211_iftype.
4512 */
4513 struct ieee80211_ops {
4514 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4515 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4516 struct sk_buff *skb);
4517 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4518 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4519 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4520 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4521 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4522 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4523 #endif
4524 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4525 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4526 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4528 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4529 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4530 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4531 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx, u32 changed);
4532 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4533 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4535 u64 changed);
4536 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4537 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4538 u64 changed);
4539 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4541 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4542 u64 changed);
4543
4544 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4545 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4546 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4547 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4548
4549 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4550 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4551 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4552 unsigned int changed_flags,
4553 unsigned int *total_flags,
4554 u64 multicast);
4555 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4556 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4557 unsigned int filter_flags,
4558 unsigned int changed_flags);
4559 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4560 bool set);
4561 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4562 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4563 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4564 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4565 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4566 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4567 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4568 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4569 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4572 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4573 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4574 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4575 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4576 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4577 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4578 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4579 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4580 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4581 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4582 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4583 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4584 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4585 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4586 const u8 *mac_addr);
4587 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4588 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4589 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4590 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4591 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4593 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4594 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4595 u32 value);
4596 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4597 u32 value);
4598 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4599 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4600 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4601 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4602 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4603 void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4604 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4605 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4606 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4607 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4608 struct dentry *dir);
4609 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4610 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4611 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4612 struct dentry *dir);
4613 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4614 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4615 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4616 struct dentry *dir);
4617 #endif
4618 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4619 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4620 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4621 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4622 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4623 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4624 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4625 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4626 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4627 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4628 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4629 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4630 void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4631 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4632 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4633 u32 changed);
4634 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4635 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4636 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4637 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4638 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4639 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4640 struct station_info *sinfo);
4641 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4642 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4643 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4644 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4645 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4646 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4647 u64 tsf);
4648 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4649 s64 offset);
4650 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4651 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4652 void (*link_sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4653 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4654 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4655 struct link_station_info *link_sinfo);
4656
4657 /**
4658 * @ampdu_action:
4659 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4660 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4661 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4662 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4663 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4664 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4665 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4666 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4667 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4668 *
4669 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4670 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4671 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4672 *
4673 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4674 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4675 *
4676 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4677 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4678 * - ``TX: 81``
4679 *
4680 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4681 *
4682 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4683 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4684 * if the session can start immediately.
4685 *
4686 * The callback can sleep.
4687 */
4688 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4689 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4690 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4691 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4692 struct survey_info *survey);
4693 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4694 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4695 s16 coverage_class);
4696 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4697 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4698 void *data, int len);
4699 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4700 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4701 void *data, int len);
4702 #endif
4703 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4704 u32 queues, bool drop);
4705 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4706 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4707 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4708 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4709 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4710 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4711 u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4712 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4713 u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4714
4715 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4716 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4717 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4718 int duration,
4719 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4720 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4721 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4722 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4723 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4724 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4725 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4726 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4727 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4728 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4729 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4730 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4731
4732 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4733 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4734 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4735 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4736 bool more_data);
4737 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4738 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4739 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4740 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4741 bool more_data);
4742
4743 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4744 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4745 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4746 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4747 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4748 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4749 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4750 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4751
4752 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4753 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4754 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4755 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4756 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4757 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4758
4759 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4760 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4761 unsigned int link_id);
4762
4763 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4764 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4765 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4766 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4767 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4768 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4769 u32 changed);
4770 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4771 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4772 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4773 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4774 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4775 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4776 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4777 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4778 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4779 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4780 int n_vifs,
4781 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4782
4783 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4784 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4785
4786 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4787 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4788 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4789 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4790 #endif
4791 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4792 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4793 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4794 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4795 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4796 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4797
4798 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4799 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4800 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4801 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4802 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4803 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4804 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4805 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4806 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4807
4808 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4809 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4810 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4811 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4812 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4813 unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4814
4815 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4816 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4817 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4818 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4819 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4820 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4821 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4822 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4823 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4824 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4825 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4826
4827 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4828 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4829 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4830
4831 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4832 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4833 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4834 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4835 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4836 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4837 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4838 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4839 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4840 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4841 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4842 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4843 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4844 u8 instance_id);
4845 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4846 struct sk_buff *head,
4847 struct sk_buff *skb);
4848 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4849 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4850 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4851 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4852 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4853 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4854 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4855 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4856 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4857 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4858 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4859 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4860 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4861 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4862 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4863 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4864 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4865 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4866 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4867 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4868 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4869 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4870 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4871 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4872 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4873 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4874 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4875 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4876 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4877 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4878 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4879 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4880 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4881 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4882 struct net_device_path *path);
4883 bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4884 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4885 u16 active_links);
4886 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4887 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4888 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4889 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4890 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4891 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4892 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4893 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4894 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4895 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4896 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4897 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4898 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4899 struct net_device *dev,
4900 enum tc_setup_type type,
4901 void *type_data);
4902 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4903 (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4904 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4905 void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4906 enum nl80211_iftype type);
4907 };
4908
4909 /**
4910 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4911 *
4912 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4913 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4914 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4915 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4916 * @priv_data_len.
4917 *
4918 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4919 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4920 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4921 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4922 *
4923 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4924 */
4925 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4926 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4927 const char *requested_name);
4928
4929 /**
4930 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4931 *
4932 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4933 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4934 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4935 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4936 * @priv_data_len.
4937 *
4938 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4939 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4940 *
4941 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4942 */
4943 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4944 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4945 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4946 {
4947 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4948 }
4949
4950 /**
4951 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4952 *
4953 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4954 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4955 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4956 *
4957 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4958 *
4959 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4960 */
4961 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4962
4963 /**
4964 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4965 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4966 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4967 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4968 */
4969 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4970 int throughput;
4971 int blink_time;
4972 };
4973
4974 /**
4975 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4976 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4977 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4978 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4979 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4980 */
4981 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4982 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4983 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4984 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4985 };
4986
4987 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4988 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4989 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4990 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4991 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4992 const char *
4993 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4994 unsigned int flags,
4995 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4996 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4997 #endif
4998 /**
4999 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
5000 *
5001 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5002 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5003 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5004 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5005 *
5006 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5007 *
5008 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5009 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5010 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5011 {
5012 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5013 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
5014 #else
5015 return NULL;
5016 #endif
5017 }
5018
5019 /**
5020 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
5021 *
5022 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5023 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5024 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5025 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5026 *
5027 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5028 *
5029 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5030 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5031 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5032 {
5033 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5034 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
5035 #else
5036 return NULL;
5037 #endif
5038 }
5039
5040 /**
5041 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
5042 *
5043 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5044 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5045 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5046 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5047 *
5048 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5049 *
5050 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5051 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5052 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5053 {
5054 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5055 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5056 #else
5057 return NULL;
5058 #endif
5059 }
5060
5061 /**
5062 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5063 *
5064 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5065 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5066 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5067 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5068 *
5069 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5070 *
5071 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5072 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5073 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5074 {
5075 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5076 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5077 #else
5078 return NULL;
5079 #endif
5080 }
5081
5082 /**
5083 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5084 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5085 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5086 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5087 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5088 *
5089 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5090 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5091 *
5092 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5093 */
5094 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5095 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5096 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5097 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5098 {
5099 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5100 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5101 blink_table_len);
5102 #else
5103 return NULL;
5104 #endif
5105 }
5106
5107 /**
5108 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5109 *
5110 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5111 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5112 *
5113 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5114 */
5115 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5116
5117 /**
5118 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5119 *
5120 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5121 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5122 * before calling this function.
5123 *
5124 * @hw: the hardware to free
5125 */
5126 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5127
5128 /**
5129 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5130 *
5131 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5132 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5133 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5134 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5135 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5136 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5137 *
5138 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5139 */
5140 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5141
5142 /**
5143 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5144 *
5145 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5146 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5147 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5148 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5149 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5150 *
5151 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5152 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5153 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5154 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5155 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5156 *
5157 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5158 *
5159 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5160 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5161 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5162 * @list: the destination list
5163 */
5164 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5165 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5166
5167 /**
5168 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5169 *
5170 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5171 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5172 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5173 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5174 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5175 *
5176 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5177 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5178 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5179 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5180 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5181 *
5182 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5183 *
5184 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5185 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5186 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5187 * @napi: the NAPI context
5188 */
5189 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5190 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5191
5192 /**
5193 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5194 *
5195 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5196 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5197 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5198 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5199 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5200 *
5201 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5202 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5203 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5204 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5205 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5206 *
5207 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5208 *
5209 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5210 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5211 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5212 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5213 {
5214 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5215 }
5216
5217 /**
5218 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5219 *
5220 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5221 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5222 *
5223 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5224 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5225 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5226 *
5227 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5228 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5229 */
5230 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5231
5232 /**
5233 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5234 *
5235 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5236 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5237 *
5238 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5239 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5240 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5241 *
5242 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5243 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5244 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5245 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5246 struct sk_buff *skb)
5247 {
5248 local_bh_disable();
5249 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5250 local_bh_enable();
5251 }
5252
5253 /**
5254 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5255 *
5256 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5257 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5258 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5259 *
5260 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5261 *
5262 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5263 * each other.
5264 *
5265 * @sta: currently connected sta
5266 * @start: start or stop PS
5267 *
5268 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5269 */
5270 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5271
5272 /**
5273 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5274 * (in process context)
5275 *
5276 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5277 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5278 * applies.
5279 *
5280 * @sta: currently connected sta
5281 * @start: start or stop PS
5282 *
5283 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5284 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5285 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5286 bool start)
5287 {
5288 int ret;
5289
5290 local_bh_disable();
5291 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5292 local_bh_enable();
5293
5294 return ret;
5295 }
5296
5297 /**
5298 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5299 * @sta: currently connected station
5300 *
5301 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5302 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5303 * connected station was received.
5304 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5305 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5306 * be serialized.
5307 */
5308 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5309
5310 /**
5311 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5312 * @sta: currently connected station
5313 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5314 *
5315 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5316 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5317 * from a connected station was received.
5318 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5319 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5320 * serialized.
5321 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5322 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5323 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5324 * checks.
5325 */
5326 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5327
5328 /*
5329 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5330 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5331 */
5332 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5333
5334 /**
5335 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5336 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5337 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5338 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5339 *
5340 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5341 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5342 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5343 *
5344 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5345 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5346 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5347 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5348 *
5349 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5350 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5351 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5352 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5353 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5354 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5355 *
5356 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5357 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5358 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5359 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5360 * use this API.
5361 */
5362 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5363 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5364
5365 /**
5366 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5367 *
5368 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5369 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5370 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5371 *
5372 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5373 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5374 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5375 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5376 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5377 */
5378 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5379 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5380 struct sk_buff *skb,
5381 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5382 int max_rates);
5383
5384 /**
5385 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5386 *
5387 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5388 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5389 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5390 *
5391 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5392 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5393 * @info: tx status information
5394 */
5395 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5396 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5397 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5398
5399 /**
5400 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5401 *
5402 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5403 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5404 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5405 *
5406 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5407 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5408 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5409 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5410 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5411 *
5412 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5413 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5414 */
5415 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5416 struct sk_buff *skb);
5417
5418 /**
5419 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5420 *
5421 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5422 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5423 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5424 *
5425 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5426 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5427 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5428 *
5429 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5430 * @status: tx status information
5431 */
5432 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5433 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5434
5435 /**
5436 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5437 *
5438 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5439 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5440 * specific skbs.
5441 *
5442 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5443 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5444 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5445 *
5446 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5447 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5448 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5449 * @info: tx status information
5450 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5451 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5452 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5453 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5454 {
5455 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5456 .sta = sta,
5457 .info = info,
5458 };
5459
5460 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5461 }
5462
5463 /**
5464 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5465 *
5466 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5467 *
5468 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5469 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5470 * for a single hardware.
5471 *
5472 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5473 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5474 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5475 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5476 struct sk_buff *skb)
5477 {
5478 local_bh_disable();
5479 ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5480 local_bh_enable();
5481 }
5482
5483 /**
5484 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5485 *
5486 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5487 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5488 *
5489 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5490 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5491 *
5492 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5493 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5494 */
5495 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5496 struct sk_buff *skb);
5497
5498 /**
5499 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5500 *
5501 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5502 * connected STA.
5503 *
5504 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5505 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5506 */
5507 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5508
5509 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5510
5511 /**
5512 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5513 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5514 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5515 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5516 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5517 * should be ignored.
5518 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5519 */
5520 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5521 u16 tim_offset;
5522 u16 tim_length;
5523
5524 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5525 u16 mbssid_off;
5526 };
5527
5528 /**
5529 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5530 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5531 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5532 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5533 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5534 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5535 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5536 *
5537 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5538 * obtain the beacon template.
5539 *
5540 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5541 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5542 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5543 * applicable, the CSA count.
5544 *
5545 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5546 *
5547 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5548 */
5549 struct sk_buff *
5550 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5551 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5552 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5553 unsigned int link_id);
5554
5555 /**
5556 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5557 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5558 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5559 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5560 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5561 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5562 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5563 *
5564 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5565 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5566 * requested index.
5567 *
5568 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5569 */
5570 struct sk_buff *
5571 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5572 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5573 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5574 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5575
5576 /**
5577 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5578 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5579 *
5580 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5581 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5582 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5583 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5584 */
5585 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5586 u8 cnt;
5587 struct {
5588 struct sk_buff *skb;
5589 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5590 } bcn[];
5591 };
5592
5593 /**
5594 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5595 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5596 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5597 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5598 *
5599 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5600 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5601 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5602 * one multiple BSSID element.
5603 *
5604 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5605 *
5606 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5607 * %NULL on error.
5608 */
5609 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5610 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5611 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5612 unsigned int link_id);
5613
5614 /**
5615 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5616 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5617 *
5618 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5619 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5620 */
5621 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5622
5623 /**
5624 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5625 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5626 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5627 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5628 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5629 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5630 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5631 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5632 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5633 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5634 *
5635 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5636 * obtain the beacon frame.
5637 *
5638 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5639 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5640 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5641 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5642 *
5643 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5644 *
5645 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5646 */
5647 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5648 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5649 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5650 unsigned int link_id);
5651
5652 /**
5653 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5654 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5655 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5656 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5657 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5658 *
5659 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5660 *
5661 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5662 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5663 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5664 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5665 unsigned int link_id)
5666 {
5667 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5668 }
5669
5670 /**
5671 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5672 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5673 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5674 *
5675 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5676 * This function is called implicitly when
5677 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5678 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5679 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5680 *
5681 * Return: new countdown value
5682 */
5683 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5684 unsigned int link_id);
5685
5686 /**
5687 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5688 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5689 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5690 *
5691 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5692 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5693 *
5694 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5695 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5696 */
5697 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5698
5699 /**
5700 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5701 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5702 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5703 *
5704 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5705 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5706 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5707 */
5708 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5709
5710 /**
5711 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5712 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5713 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5714 *
5715 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5716 */
5717 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5718 unsigned int link_id);
5719
5720 /**
5721 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5722 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5723 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5724 *
5725 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5726 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5727 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5728 */
5729 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5730
5731 /**
5732 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5733 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5734 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5735 *
5736 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5737 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5738 *
5739 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5740 *
5741 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5742 */
5743 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5744 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5745
5746 /**
5747 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5748 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5749 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5750 *
5751 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5752 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5753 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5754 *
5755 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5756 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5757 *
5758 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5759 */
5760 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5761 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5762
5763 /**
5764 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5765 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5766 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5767 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5768 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5769 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5770 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5771 * if at all possible
5772 *
5773 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5774 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5775 * BSSID and address is used.
5776 *
5777 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5778 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5779 *
5780 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5781 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5782 *
5783 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5784 */
5785 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5786 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5787 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5788
5789 /**
5790 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5791 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5792 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5793 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5794 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5795 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5796 *
5797 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5798 * hardware.
5799 *
5800 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5801 */
5802 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5803 const u8 *src_addr,
5804 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5805 size_t tailroom);
5806
5807 /**
5808 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5809 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5810 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5811 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5812 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5813 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5814 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5815 *
5816 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5817 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5818 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5819 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5820 */
5821 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5822 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5823 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5824 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5825
5826 /**
5827 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5828 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5829 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5830 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5831 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5832 *
5833 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5834 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5835 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5836 *
5837 * Return: The duration.
5838 */
5839 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5840 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5841 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5842
5843 /**
5844 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5845 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5846 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5847 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5848 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5849 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5850 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5851 *
5852 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5853 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5854 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5855 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5856 */
5857 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5858 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5859 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5860 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5861 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5862
5863 /**
5864 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5865 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5866 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5867 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5868 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5869 *
5870 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5871 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5872 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5873 *
5874 * Return: The duration.
5875 */
5876 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5877 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5878 size_t frame_len,
5879 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5880
5881 /**
5882 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5883 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5884 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5885 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5886 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5887 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5888 *
5889 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5890 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5891 *
5892 * Return: The duration.
5893 */
5894 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5895 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5896 enum nl80211_band band,
5897 size_t frame_len,
5898 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5899
5900 /**
5901 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5902 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5903 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5904 *
5905 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5906 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5907 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5908 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5909 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5910 *
5911 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5912 * frames are available.
5913 *
5914 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5915 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5916 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5917 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5918 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5919 * use common code for all beacons.
5920 */
5921 struct sk_buff *
5922 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5923
5924 /**
5925 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5926 *
5927 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5928 *
5929 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5930 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5931 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5932 */
5933 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5934 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5935
5936 /**
5937 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5938 *
5939 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5940 * from the given packet.
5941 *
5942 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5943 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5944 * with this P1K
5945 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5946 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5947 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5948 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5949 {
5950 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5951 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5952 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5953
5954 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5955 }
5956
5957 /**
5958 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5959 *
5960 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5961 * and transmitter address.
5962 *
5963 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5964 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5965 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5966 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5967 */
5968 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5969 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5970
5971 /**
5972 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5973 *
5974 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5975 * in the packet.
5976 *
5977 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5978 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5979 * encrypted with this key
5980 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5981 */
5982 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5983 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5984
5985 /**
5986 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5987 *
5988 * @pos: start of crypto header
5989 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5990 * @pn: PN to add
5991 *
5992 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5993 * the packet payload)
5994 *
5995 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5996 * point to the crypto header)
5997 */
5998 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5999
6000 /**
6001 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
6002 *
6003 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6004 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6005 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6006 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6007 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
6008 *
6009 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
6010 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
6011 * by the device and not by mac80211.
6012 *
6013 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6014 * can be done concurrently.
6015 */
6016 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6017 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6018
6019 /**
6020 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
6021 *
6022 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6023 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6024 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6025 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6026 * @seq: new sequence data
6027 *
6028 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
6029 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
6030 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
6031 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6032 *
6033 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6034 * can be done concurrently.
6035 */
6036 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6037 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6038
6039 /**
6040 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6041 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6042 * @idx: the keyidx of the key
6043 * @key_data: the key data
6044 * @key_len: the key data. Might be bigger than the actual key length,
6045 * but not smaller (for the driver convinence)
6046 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6047 *
6048 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6049 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6050 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6051 *
6052 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6053 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6054 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6055 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6056 *
6057 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6058 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6059 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6060 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6061 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6062 * of the reconfiguration.
6063 *
6064 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6065 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6066 *
6067 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6068 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call.
6069 */
6070 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6071 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6072 u8 idx, u8 *key_data, u8 key_len,
6073 int link_id);
6074
6075 /**
6076 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6077 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6078 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6079 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6080 * @gfp: allocation flags
6081 */
6082 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6083 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6084
6085 /**
6086 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6087 *
6088 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6089 * at the same time.
6090 *
6091 * @keyconf: the key in question
6092 */
6093 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6094
6095 /**
6096 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6097 *
6098 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6099 * at the same time.
6100 *
6101 * @keyconf: the key in question
6102 */
6103 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6104
6105 /**
6106 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6107 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6108 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6109 *
6110 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6111 */
6112 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6113
6114 /**
6115 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6116 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6117 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6118 *
6119 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6120 */
6121 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6122
6123 /**
6124 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6125 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6126 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6127 *
6128 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6129 *
6130 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6131 */
6132
6133 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6134
6135 /**
6136 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6137 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6138 *
6139 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6140 */
6141 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6142
6143 /**
6144 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6145 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6146 *
6147 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6148 */
6149 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6150
6151 /**
6152 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6153 *
6154 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6155 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6156 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6157 * any context, including hardirq context.
6158 *
6159 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6160 * @info: information about the completed scan
6161 */
6162 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6163 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6164
6165 /**
6166 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6167 *
6168 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6169 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6170 *
6171 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6172 */
6173 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6174
6175 /**
6176 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6177 *
6178 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6179 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6180 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6181 * while associating, for instance.
6182 *
6183 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6184 */
6185 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6186
6187 /**
6188 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6189 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6190 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6191 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6192 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6193 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6194 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6195 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6196 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6197 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6198 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6199 * for instance.
6200 */
6201 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6202 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
6203 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
6204 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
6205 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
6206 };
6207
6208 /**
6209 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6210 *
6211 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6212 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6213 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6214 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6215 *
6216 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6217 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6218 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6219 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6220 */
6221 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6222 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6223 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6224 void *data);
6225
6226 /**
6227 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6228 *
6229 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6230 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6231 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6232 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6233 * be used.
6234 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6235 *
6236 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6237 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6238 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6239 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6240 */
6241 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6242 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6243 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6244 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6245 void *data)
6246 {
6247 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6248 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6249 iterator, data);
6250 }
6251
6252 /**
6253 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6254 *
6255 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6256 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6257 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6258 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6259 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6260 *
6261 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6262 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6263 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6264 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6265 */
6266 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6267 u32 iter_flags,
6268 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6269 u8 *mac,
6270 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6271 void *data);
6272
6273 /**
6274 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6275 *
6276 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6277 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6278 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6279 *
6280 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6281 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6282 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6283 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6284 */
6285 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6286 u32 iter_flags,
6287 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6288 u8 *mac,
6289 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6290 void *data);
6291
6292 /**
6293 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6294 *
6295 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6296 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6297 * function for them.
6298 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6299 *
6300 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6301 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6302 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6303 */
6304 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6305 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6306 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6307 void *data);
6308
6309 /**
6310 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6311 *
6312 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6313 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6314 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6315 * mutex.
6316 *
6317 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6318 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6319 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6320 */
6321 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6322 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6323 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6324 void *data);
6325
6326 /**
6327 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6328 *
6329 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6330 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6331 *
6332 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6333 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6334 */
6335 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6336
6337 /**
6338 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6339 *
6340 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6341 * workqueue.
6342 *
6343 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6344 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6345 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6346 */
6347 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6348 struct delayed_work *dwork,
6349 unsigned long delay);
6350
6351 /**
6352 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6353 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6354 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6355 *
6356 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6357 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6358 * mac80211.
6359 *
6360 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6361 */
6362 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6363 u16 tid);
6364
6365 /**
6366 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6367 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6368 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6369 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6370 *
6371 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6372 *
6373 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6374 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6375 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6376 */
6377 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6378 u16 timeout);
6379
6380 /**
6381 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6382 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6383 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6384 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6385 *
6386 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6387 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6388 * from any context.
6389 */
6390 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6391 u16 tid);
6392
6393 /**
6394 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6395 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6396 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6397 *
6398 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6399 *
6400 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6401 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6402 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6403 */
6404 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6405
6406 /**
6407 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6408 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6409 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6410 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6411 *
6412 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6413 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6414 * can be called from any context.
6415 */
6416 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6417 u16 tid);
6418
6419 /**
6420 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6421 *
6422 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6423 * @addr: station's address
6424 *
6425 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6426 *
6427 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6428 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6429 */
6430 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6431 const u8 *addr);
6432
6433 /**
6434 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6435 *
6436 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6437 * @addr: remote station's address
6438 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6439 *
6440 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6441 *
6442 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6443 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6444 *
6445 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6446 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6447 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6448 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6449 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6450 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6451 * is not reliable.
6452 *
6453 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6454 */
6455 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6456 const u8 *addr,
6457 const u8 *localaddr);
6458
6459 /**
6460 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6461 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6462 * @addr: remote station's link address
6463 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6464 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6465 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6466 *
6467 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6468 *
6469 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6470 */
6471 struct ieee80211_sta *
6472 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6473 const u8 *addr,
6474 const u8 *localaddr,
6475 unsigned int *link_id);
6476
6477 /**
6478 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6479 * @hw: the hardware
6480 * @pubsta: the station
6481 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6482 *
6483 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6484 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6485 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6486 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6487 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6488 *
6489 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6490 * manner.
6491 *
6492 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6493 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6494 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6495 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6496 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6497 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6498 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6499 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6500 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6501 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6502 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6503 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6504 * woke up while blocked or not.
6505 */
6506 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6507 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6508
6509 /**
6510 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6511 * @pubsta: the station
6512 *
6513 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6514 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6515 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6516 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6517 *
6518 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6519 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6520 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6521 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6522 *
6523 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6524 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6525 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6526 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6527 */
6528 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6529
6530 /**
6531 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6532 * @pubsta: the station
6533 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6534 *
6535 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6536 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6537 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6538 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6539 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6540 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6541 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6542 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6543 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6544 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6545 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6546 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6547 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6548 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6549 */
6550 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6551
6552 /**
6553 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6554 * @pubsta: the station
6555 *
6556 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6557 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6558 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6559 *
6560 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6561 * there is no need to call this function.
6562 */
6563 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6564
6565 /**
6566 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6567 *
6568 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6569 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6570 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6571 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6572 *
6573 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6574 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6575 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6576 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6577 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6578 * attempts.
6579 *
6580 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6581 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6582 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6583 * them to 0.
6584 *
6585 * @pubsta: the station
6586 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6587 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6588 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6589 */
6590 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6591 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6592
6593 /**
6594 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6595 *
6596 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6597 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6598 *
6599 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6600 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6601 */
6602 bool
6603 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6604
6605 /**
6606 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6607 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6608 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6609 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6610 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6611 *
6612 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6613 *
6614 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6615 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6616 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6617 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6618 *
6619 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6620 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6621 * set_key callback.
6622 */
6623 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6624 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6625 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6626 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6627 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6628 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6629 void *data),
6630 void *iter_data);
6631
6632 /**
6633 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6634 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6635 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6636 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6637 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6638 *
6639 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6640 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6641 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6642 * in removal process will be skipped.
6643 *
6644 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6645 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6646 */
6647 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6648 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6649 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6650 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6651 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6652 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6653 void *data),
6654 void *iter_data);
6655
6656 /**
6657 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6658 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6659 * @iter: iterator function
6660 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6661 *
6662 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6663 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6664 * places while calling into the driver.
6665 *
6666 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6667 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6668 * removed.
6669 *
6670 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6671 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6672 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6673 * or not.
6674 */
6675 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6676 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6677 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6678 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6679 void *data),
6680 void *iter_data);
6681
6682 /**
6683 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx - iterate channel contexts
6684 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6685 * @iter: iterator function
6686 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6687 *
6688 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function can only be used while
6689 * holding the wiphy mutex.
6690 *
6691 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6692 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6693 * removed.
6694 *
6695 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6696 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6697 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6698 * or not.
6699 */
6700 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx(
6701 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6702 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6703 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6704 void *data),
6705 void *iter_data);
6706
6707 /**
6708 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6709 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6710 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6711 *
6712 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6713 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6714 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6715 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6716 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6717 * %NULL.
6718 *
6719 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6720 */
6721 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6722 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6723
6724 /**
6725 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6726 *
6727 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6728 *
6729 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6730 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6731 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6732 */
6733 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6734
6735 /**
6736 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6737 *
6738 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6739 *
6740 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6741 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6742 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6743 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6744 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6745 *
6746 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6747 * without connection recovery attempts.
6748 */
6749 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6750
6751 /**
6752 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6753 *
6754 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6755 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6756 *
6757 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6758 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6759 */
6760 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6761
6762 /**
6763 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6764 *
6765 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6766 *
6767 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6768 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6769 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6770 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6771 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6772 *
6773 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6774 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6775 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6776 * disconnect normally later.
6777 *
6778 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6779 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6780 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6781 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6782 */
6783 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6784
6785 /**
6786 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6787 * hardware restart
6788 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6789 *
6790 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6791 * hardware restart.
6792 */
6793 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6794
6795 /**
6796 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6797 * rssi threshold triggered
6798 *
6799 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6800 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6801 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6802 * @gfp: context flags
6803 *
6804 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6805 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6806 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6807 */
6808 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6809 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6810 s32 rssi_level,
6811 gfp_t gfp);
6812
6813 /**
6814 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6815 *
6816 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6817 * @gfp: context flags
6818 */
6819 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6820
6821 /**
6822 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6823 *
6824 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6825 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6826 * pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6827 */
6828 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6829 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6830
6831 /**
6832 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6833 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6834 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6835 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6836 * false.
6837 *
6838 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6839 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6840 */
6841 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6842 unsigned int link_id);
6843
6844 /**
6845 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6846 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6847 *
6848 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6849 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6850 * a deauth frame in this case.
6851 */
6852 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6853
6854 /**
6855 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6856 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6857 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6858 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6859 *
6860 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6861 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6862 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6863 */
6864 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6865 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6866
6867 /**
6868 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6869 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6870 */
6871 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6872
6873 /**
6874 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6875 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6876 */
6877 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6878
6879 /**
6880 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6881 *
6882 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6883 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6884 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6885 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6886 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6887 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6888 *
6889 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6890 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6891 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6892 */
6893 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6894 const u8 *addr);
6895
6896 /**
6897 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6898 * @pubsta: station struct
6899 * @tid: the session's TID
6900 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6901 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
6902 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6903 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6904 *
6905 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6906 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6907 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6908 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6909 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6910 */
6911 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6912 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6913 u16 received_mpdus);
6914
6915 /**
6916 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6917 *
6918 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6919 * buffer.
6920 *
6921 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6922 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6923 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6924 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6925 */
6926 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6927
6928 /**
6929 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6930 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6931 * @addr: station mac address
6932 * @tid: the rx tid
6933 */
6934 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6935 unsigned int tid);
6936
6937 /**
6938 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6939 *
6940 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6941 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6942 * reordering.
6943 *
6944 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6945 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6946 *
6947 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6948 * @addr: station mac address
6949 * @tid: the rx tid
6950 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6951 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6952 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6953 {
6954 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6955 return;
6956 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6957 }
6958
6959 /**
6960 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6961 *
6962 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6963 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6964 * reordering.
6965 *
6966 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6967 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6968 *
6969 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6970 * @addr: station mac address
6971 * @tid: the rx tid
6972 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6973 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6974 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6975 {
6976 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6977 return;
6978 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6979 }
6980
6981 /**
6982 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6983 *
6984 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6985 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6986 *
6987 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6988 *
6989 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6990 * @addr: station mac address
6991 * @tid: the rx tid
6992 */
6993 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6994 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6995
6996 /* Rate control API */
6997
6998 /**
6999 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
7000 *
7001 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
7002 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
7003 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
7004 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
7005 * to be filled in
7006 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
7007 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
7008 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
7009 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
7010 * RTS threshold
7011 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
7012 * if the selected rate supports it
7013 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
7014 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
7015 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
7016 */
7017 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
7018 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
7019 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
7020 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
7021 struct sk_buff *skb;
7022 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
7023 bool rts, short_preamble;
7024 u32 rate_idx_mask;
7025 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
7026 bool bss;
7027 };
7028
7029 /**
7030 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
7031 */
7032 enum rate_control_capabilities {
7033 /**
7034 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
7035 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
7036 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
7037 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
7038 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
7039 */
7040 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
7041 /**
7042 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
7043 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
7044 */
7045 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7046 };
7047
7048 struct rate_control_ops {
7049 unsigned long capa;
7050 const char *name;
7051 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7052 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7053 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7054 void (*free)(void *priv);
7055
7056 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7057 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7058 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7059 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7060 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7061 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7062 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7063 u32 changed);
7064 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7065 void *priv_sta);
7066
7067 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7068 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7069 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7070 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7071 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7072 struct sk_buff *skb);
7073 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7074 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7075
7076 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7077 struct dentry *dir);
7078
7079 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7080 };
7081
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7082 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7083 enum nl80211_band band,
7084 int index)
7085 {
7086 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7087 }
7088
7089 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7090 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7091 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7092 {
7093 int i;
7094
7095 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7096 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7097 return i;
7098
7099 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7100 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7101
7102 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7103 return 0;
7104 }
7105
7106 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7107 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7108 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7109 {
7110 unsigned int i;
7111
7112 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7113 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7114 return true;
7115 return false;
7116 }
7117
7118 /**
7119 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7120 *
7121 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7122 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7123 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7124 * the most recent rate control module decision.
7125 *
7126 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7127 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7128 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7129 *
7130 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7131 */
7132 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7133 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7134 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7135
7136 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7137 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7138
7139 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7140 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7141 {
7142 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7143 }
7144
7145 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7146 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7147 {
7148 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7149 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7150 }
7151
7152 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7153 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7154 {
7155 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7156 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7157 }
7158
7159 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7160 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7161 {
7162 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7163 }
7164
7165 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7166 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7167 {
7168 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7169 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7170 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7171 }
7172
7173 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7174 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7175 {
7176 if (p2p) {
7177 switch (type) {
7178 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7179 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7180 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7181 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7182 default:
7183 break;
7184 }
7185 }
7186 return type;
7187 }
7188
7189 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7190 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7191 {
7192 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7193 }
7194
7195 /**
7196 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7197 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7198 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7199 *
7200 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7201 */
7202 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7203 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7204 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7205 {
7206 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7207 }
7208
7209 /**
7210 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7211 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7212 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7213 *
7214 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7215 */
7216 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7217 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7218 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7219 {
7220 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7221 }
7222
7223 /**
7224 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7225 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7226 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7227 *
7228 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7229 */
7230 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7231 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7232 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7233 {
7234 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7235 }
7236
7237 /**
7238 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7239 *
7240 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7241 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7242 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7243 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7244 *
7245 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7246 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7247 * matching GroupId management frame.
7248 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7249 */
7250 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7251 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7252
7253 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7254 int rssi_min_thold,
7255 int rssi_max_thold);
7256
7257 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7258
7259 /**
7260 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7261 *
7262 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7263 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO
7264 *
7265 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7266 *
7267 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7268 * applicable.
7269 */
7270 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int link_id);
7271
7272 /**
7273 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7274 * @vif: virtual interface
7275 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7276 * @gfp: allocation flags
7277 *
7278 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7279 */
7280 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7281 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7282 gfp_t gfp);
7283
7284 /**
7285 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7286 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7287 * @vif: virtual interface
7288 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7289 * @band: the band to transmit on
7290 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7291 *
7292 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7293 *
7294 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7295 */
7296 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7297 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7298 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7299
7300 /**
7301 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7302 * of injected frames.
7303 *
7304 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7305 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7306 * of the skb before calling this function.
7307 *
7308 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7309 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7310 *
7311 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7312 */
7313 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7314 struct net_device *dev);
7315
7316 /**
7317 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7318 *
7319 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7320 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7321 *
7322 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7323 *
7324 * private:
7325 *
7326 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7327 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7328 */
7329 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7330 u32 next_tsf;
7331 bool has_next_tsf;
7332
7333 u8 absent;
7334
7335 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7336 struct {
7337 u32 start;
7338 u32 duration;
7339 u32 interval;
7340 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7341 };
7342
7343 /**
7344 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7345 *
7346 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7347 * @data: NoA tracking data
7348 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7349 *
7350 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7351 */
7352 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7353 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7354
7355 /**
7356 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7357 *
7358 * @data: NoA tracking data
7359 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7360 */
7361 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7362
7363 /**
7364 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7365 * @vif: virtual interface
7366 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7367 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7368 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7369 * @gfp: allocation flags
7370 *
7371 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7372 */
7373 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7374 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7375 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7376
7377 /**
7378 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7379 *
7380 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7381 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7382 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7383 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7384 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7385 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7386 *
7387 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7388 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7389 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7390 *
7391 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7392 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7393 *
7394 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7395 */
7396 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7397
7398 /**
7399 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7400 *
7401 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7402 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7403 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7404 *
7405 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7406 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7407 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7408 *
7409 * @sta: the station
7410 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7411 */
7412 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7413
7414 /**
7415 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7416 *
7417 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7418 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7419 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7420 *
7421 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7422 *
7423 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7424 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7425 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7426 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7427 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7428 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7429 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7430 *
7431 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7432 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7433 */
7434 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7435 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7436
7437 /**
7438 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7439 * (in process context)
7440 *
7441 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7442 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7443 *
7444 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7445 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7446 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7447 *
7448 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7449 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7450 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7451 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7452 {
7453 struct sk_buff *skb;
7454
7455 local_bh_disable();
7456 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7457 local_bh_enable();
7458
7459 return skb;
7460 }
7461
7462 /**
7463 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7464 *
7465 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7466 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7467 *
7468 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7469 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7470 */
7471 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7472 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7473
7474 /**
7475 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7476 *
7477 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7478 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7479 *
7480 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7481 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7482 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7483 */
7484 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7485
7486 /**
7487 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7488 *
7489 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7490 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7491 *
7492 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7493 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7494 */
7495 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7496
7497 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7498 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7499 {
7500 }
7501
7502 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7503 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7504
7505 /**
7506 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7507 *
7508 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7509 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7510 *
7511 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7512 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7513 *
7514 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7515 * this TXQ internally.
7516 */
7517 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7518 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7519 {
7520 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7521 }
7522
7523 /**
7524 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7525 *
7526 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7527 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7528 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7529 *
7530 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7531 * internally.
7532 */
7533 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7534 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7535 bool force)
7536 {
7537 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7538 }
7539
7540 /**
7541 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7542 *
7543 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7544 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7545 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7546 * next_txq().
7547 *
7548 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7549 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7550 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7551 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7552 * again.
7553 *
7554 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7555 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7556 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7557 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7558 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7559 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7560 *
7561 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7562 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7563 *
7564 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7565 */
7566 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7567 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7568
7569 /**
7570 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7571 *
7572 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7573 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7574 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7575 *
7576 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7577 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7578 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7579 */
7580 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7581 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7582 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7583
7584 /**
7585 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7586 *
7587 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7588 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7589 *
7590 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7591 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7592 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7593 * @gfp: allocation flags
7594 */
7595 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7596 u8 inst_id,
7597 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7598 gfp_t gfp);
7599
7600 /**
7601 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7602 *
7603 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7604 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7605 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7606 *
7607 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7608 * @match: match event information
7609 * @gfp: allocation flags
7610 */
7611 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7612 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7613 gfp_t gfp);
7614
7615 /**
7616 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7617 *
7618 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7619 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7620 *
7621 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7622 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7623 * information.
7624 * @len: frame length in bytes
7625 *
7626 * Return: the airtime estimate
7627 */
7628 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7629 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7630 int len);
7631
7632 /**
7633 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7634 *
7635 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7636 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7637 *
7638 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7639 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7640 * @len: frame length in bytes
7641 *
7642 * Return: the airtime estimate
7643 */
7644 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7645 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7646 int len);
7647 /**
7648 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7649 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7650 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7651 *
7652 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7653 *
7654 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7655 */
7656 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7657 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7658
7659 /**
7660 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7661 * probe response template.
7662 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7663 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7664 *
7665 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7666 *
7667 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7668 */
7669 struct sk_buff *
7670 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7671 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7672
7673 /**
7674 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7675 * collision.
7676 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7677 *
7678 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7679 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7680 * aware of.
7681 */
7682 void
7683 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7684 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7685
7686 /**
7687 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7688 *
7689 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7690 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7691 *
7692 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7693 *
7694 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7695 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7696 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7697 {
7698 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7699 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7700
7701 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7702 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7703 }
7704
7705 /**
7706 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7707 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7708 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7709 *
7710 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7711 * back into the driver.
7712 *
7713 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7714 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7715 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7716 *
7717 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7718 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7719 * a sequence of calls like
7720 *
7721 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
7722 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7723 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7724 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7725 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7726 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7727 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7728 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7729 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
7730 *
7731 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7732 */
7733 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7734
7735 /**
7736 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7737 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7738 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7739 *
7740 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7741 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7742 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7743 * completed after it returns.
7744 */
7745 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7746 u16 active_links);
7747
7748 /**
7749 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7750 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7751 *
7752 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7753 * TTLM request.
7754 */
7755 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7756
7757 /**
7758 * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
7759 * @width: the channel width value to convert
7760 * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
7761 */
7762 static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)7763 ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
7764 {
7765 switch (width) {
7766 default:
7767 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7768 fallthrough;
7769 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
7770 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
7771 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
7772 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
7773 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
7774 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
7775 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
7776 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
7777 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
7778 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
7779 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
7780 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
7781 }
7782 }
7783
7784 /**
7785 * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
7786 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
7787 * @bw: the bandwidth requested
7788 *
7789 * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
7790 * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
7791 * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
7792 *
7793 * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
7794 * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
7795 * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
7796 * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
7797 *
7798 * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
7799 * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
7800 * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
7801 *
7802 * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
7803 * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
7804 * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
7805 * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
7806 *
7807 * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
7808 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
7809 * case of HW restart.
7810 *
7811 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
7812 * into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
7813 *
7814 * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
7815 */
7816 bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
7817 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);
7818
7819 /**
7820 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
7821 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
7822 *
7823 * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
7824 * as well.
7825 */
7826 void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);
7827
7828 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7829 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7830 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7831 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7832 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7833 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7834 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7835 u32 changed);
7836 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7837 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7838 int n_vifs,
7839 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7840
7841 /**
7842 * ieee80211_vif_nan_started - Return whether a NAN vif is started
7843 * @vif: the vif
7844 * Return: %true iff the vif is a NAN interface and NAN is started
7845 */
7846 bool ieee80211_vif_nan_started(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7847 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7848